blob: 088ca96edd61ca6bace11284b077457aef4a3b6e [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000019#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000021#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000022#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000024#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000025#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000026#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
27#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000028#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000029#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000030#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000031#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000032using namespace clang;
33
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000034
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000035/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
36/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
37///
38/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
39/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
40/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
41/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
42/// function is being used.
43///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000044/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
45/// decls.
46///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000047/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
48/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000049///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000050bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000051 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000052 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000053 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000054 }
55
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000056 // See if the decl is unavailable
57 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
58 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
59 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
60 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000061
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000062 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000063 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000064 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
65 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
66 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
67 return true;
68 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000069 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000070
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000072}
73
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000074/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000075/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000076/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
77///
78void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000080 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000081 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000082 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000083
84 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
85 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
87 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000089 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
90 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000091 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000092 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
93 int isMethod = 0;
94 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
95 // skip over named parameters.
96 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
97 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
98 if (nullPos)
99 --nullPos;
100 else
101 ++i;
102 }
103 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
104 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000105 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000106 // skip over named parameters.
107 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
108 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
109 if (nullPos)
110 --nullPos;
111 else
112 ++i;
113 }
114 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000115 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000116 // block or function pointer call.
117 QualType Ty = V->getType();
118 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000119 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000120 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
121 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000122 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
123 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
124 unsigned k;
125 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
126 if (nullPos)
127 --nullPos;
128 else
129 ++i;
130 }
131 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
132 }
133 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
134 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000135 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000136 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000137 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000138 return;
139
140 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000141 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000143 return;
144 }
145 int sentinel = i;
146 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
147 --sentinelPos;
148 ++i;
149 }
150 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
151 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000152 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000153 return;
154 }
155 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
156 ++i;
157 ++sentinel;
158 }
159 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
Anders Carlssone4d2bdd2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000160 if (sentinelExpr && (!isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr) &&
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000161 !sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
162 !sentinelExpr->isValueDependent() &&
Anders Carlssone4d2bdd2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000163 (!sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
164 !sentinelExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
165 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)))) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000166 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000167 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000168 }
169 return;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000170}
171
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000172SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
173 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
174 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
175}
176
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000177//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
178// Standard Promotions and Conversions
179//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
180
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000181/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
182void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
183 QualType Ty = E->getType();
184 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
185
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000186 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000187 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000188 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000189 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
190 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
191 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
192 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
193 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
194 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
195 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000196 //
197 // C++ 4.2p1:
198 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
199 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
200 //
201 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
202 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000203 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
204 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000205 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000206}
207
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000208void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
209 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000210
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000211 QualType Ty = E->getType();
212 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
213 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
214 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
215 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
216 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
217 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
218 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
219 // rvalue is T
220 //
221 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000222 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
223 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000224 // type of the lvalue.
225 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
226 }
227}
228
229
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000230/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000231/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000232/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
233/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
234/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
235Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
236 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
237 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000239 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
240 //
241 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
242 // unsigned int may be used:
243 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
244 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
245 // and unsigned int.
246 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
247 //
248 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
249 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
250 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
251 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000252 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
253 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000254 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000255 return Expr;
256 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000257 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000258 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000259 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000260 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000261 }
262
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000263 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000264 return Expr;
265}
266
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000267/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000268/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000269/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
270void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
271 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
272 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000275 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000277 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
278 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000279
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000280 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
281}
282
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000283/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
284/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
285/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
286/// completely illegal.
287bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000288 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000289
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000290 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCInterfaceType() &&
291 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
292 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
293 << Expr->getType() << CT))
294 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000295
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000296 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000297 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000298 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
299 << Expr->getType() << CT))
300 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000301
302 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000303}
304
305
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000306/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
307/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000309/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
310/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
311/// GCC.
312QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
313 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000314 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000315 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000316
317 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000318
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000319 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000320 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000321 QualType lhs =
322 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000323 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000324 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000325
326 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
327 if (lhs == rhs)
328 return lhs;
329
330 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
331 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
332 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
333 return lhs;
334
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000335 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000336 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000337 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
338 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000339 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000340 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
341 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
342
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000343 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000344 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000345 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
346 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000347 return destType;
348}
349
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000350//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
351// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
352//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
353
354
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000355/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000356/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
357/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
358/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
359/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000360///
361Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000362Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000363 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
364
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000365 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000366 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000367 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000368
369 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
370 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
371 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000372
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000373 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000374 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000375 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000376
377 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCall4b7a8342010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000378 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000379 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000381 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
382 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
383 // strings.
384 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000385 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000387
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000388 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000389 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000390 Literal.GetStringLength(),
391 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
392 &StringTokLocs[0],
393 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000394}
395
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000396/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
397/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
398/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
399/// for values inside the block or for globals).
400///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000401/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000402/// up-to-date.
403///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000404static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000405 ValueDecl *VD) {
406 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
407 // we wanted to.
408 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
409 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000410
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000411 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
412 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
413 return false;
414
415 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
416 // snapshot it.
417 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
418 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000419 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
420 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000421
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000422 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
423 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
424
425 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
426 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
427 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
428 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000429 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
430 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000431
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000432 if (!NextBlock)
433 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
436 // having a reference outside it.
437 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
438 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000439
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000440 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
441 // a snapshot as well.
442 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
443 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000444
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000445 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000446}
447
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000448
449
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000450/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000451Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000452Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000453 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000454 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
455 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000457 << D->getDeclName();
458 return ExprError();
459 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000461 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
462 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
463 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
464 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000465 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000466 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000468 << D->getIdentifier();
469 return ExprError();
470 }
471 }
472 }
473 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000474
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000475 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000476
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000477 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
478 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
479 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000480 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000481}
482
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000483/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
484/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
485/// is Record.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000486static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
487 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000488 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000489 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000491 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
492 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
493 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000494 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000496 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000497 D != DEnd; ++D) {
498 if (*D == Record) {
499 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
500 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
501 ++D;
502 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor4afa39d2009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000503 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000504 return *D;
505 }
506 }
507
508 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
509 return 0;
510}
511
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000512/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
513/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
514/// actual member.
515///
516/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
517/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
518/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
519/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
520/// we found.
521///
522/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
523/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
524/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
525VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
526 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
528 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
529 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
530
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000531 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
533 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
534 do {
535 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000536 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000537 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000538 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000539 else {
540 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
541 break;
542 }
543 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000545 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000546
547 return BaseObject;
548}
549
550Sema::OwningExprResult
551Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
552 FieldDecl *Field,
553 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
554 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
555 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000556 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000557 AnonFields);
558
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000559 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
560 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
561 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
562 // found via name lookup.
563 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000564 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000565 if (BaseObject) {
566 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
567 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000568 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000569 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000570 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000571 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000572 BaseQuals
573 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000574 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
575 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
576 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
577 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
578 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000579 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
581 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
582 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000583 BaseQuals
584 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 } else {
586 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
587 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
588 // program our base object expression is "this".
589 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
590 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 = Context.getTagDeclType(
593 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
594 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000595 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
597 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
598 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000599 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000600 MD->getThisType(Context),
601 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
603 }
604 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000605 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
606 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000608 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
610
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000611 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000612 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
613 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000614 }
615
616 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
617 // anonymous struct/union.
618 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000619 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000620 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
621 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
622 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
623 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000624 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
625 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
626
627 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
628 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
629 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
630 ResultQuals.removeConst();
631
632 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
633 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
634
635 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
636 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
637
638 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
639 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
640 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
641
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000642 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000643 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000644 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000645 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
646 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000647 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 }
650
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000651 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652}
653
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000654/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
655/// possibly a list of template arguments.
656///
657/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
658/// DecomposeTemplateName.
659///
660/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
661/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
662/// some way.
663static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
664 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
665 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
666 DeclarationName &Name,
667 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
668 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
669 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
670 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
671 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
672
673 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
674 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
675 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
676 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
677 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
678
679 TemplateName TName =
680 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
681
682 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
683 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
684 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
685 } else {
686 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
687 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
688 TemplateArgs = 0;
689 }
690}
691
692/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
693///
694/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
695/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
696/// found template arguments.
697static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
698 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
699 TemplateName TName =
700 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
701
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000702 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
703 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000704 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
705 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
706 I != E; ++I)
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000707 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCallb681b612009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000708
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000709 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000710}
711
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000712/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
713/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
714/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000715static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000716 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
717 return false;
718
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000719 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
720 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
721 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
722 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
723 if (!BaseRT) return false;
724
725 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000726 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000727 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
728 return false;
729 }
730
731 return true;
732}
733
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000734/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
735/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
736static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000737 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000738
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000739 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
740 if (!DC) return true;
741
742 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
743 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
744
745 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
746 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
747
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000748 return false;
749}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
752/// the prospective base classes.
753static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
754 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
755 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000756 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000757 return false;
758
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000759 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000760 if (!RD) return false;
761 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
762
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000763 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
764 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
765 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
766 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
767 if (!BaseRT) return false;
768
769 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000770 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
771 return false;
772 }
773
774 return true;
775}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000776
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000777enum IMAKind {
778 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
779 IMA_Static,
780
781 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
782 IMA_Mixed,
783
784 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
785 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
786 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
787
788 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
789 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
790 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
791
792 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
793 IMA_Instance,
794
795 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
796 IMA_Unresolved,
797
798 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
799 /// context is not an instance method.
800 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
801
802 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
803 /// non-class context.
804 IMA_AnonymousMember,
805
806 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
807 /// context is not an instance method.
808 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
809
810 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
811 /// class.
812 IMA_Error_Unrelated
813};
814
815/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
816/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
817/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
818/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
819/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
820/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
821static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
822 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000823 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000824
825 bool isStaticContext =
826 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
827 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
828
829 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
830 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
831
832 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
833 bool hasNonInstance = false;
834 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
835 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000836 NamedDecl *D = *I;
837 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000838 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
839
840 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
841 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
842 // that's a special case.
843 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
844 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
845 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
846 }
847 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
848 }
849 else
850 hasNonInstance = true;
851 }
852
853 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
854 // member reference.
855 if (Classes.empty())
856 return IMA_Static;
857
858 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
859 // an implicit member reference.
860 if (isStaticContext)
861 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
862
863 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
864 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
865 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
866 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
867 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
868 Classes))
869 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
870
871 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
872}
873
874/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
875static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
876 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
877 const LookupResult &R) {
878 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
879 SourceRange Range(Loc);
880 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
881
882 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
883 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
884 if (MD->isStatic()) {
885 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
887 << Range << R.getLookupName();
888 return;
889 }
890 }
891
892 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
893 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
894 return;
895 }
896
897 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000898}
899
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000900/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
901///
902/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000903bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904 LookupResult &R) {
905 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
906
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000908 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
910 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000911 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000912 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000913 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
914 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000915
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000916 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
917 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
918 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
919 // dependent name.
920 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
921 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
923 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
924
925 if (!R.empty()) {
926 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
927 R.suppressDiagnostics();
928
929 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
930 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
931 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
932 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
933
934 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
935 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
936 // Actually quite difficult!
937 if (isInstance)
938 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000939 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000940 else
941 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
942
943 // Do we really want to note all of these?
944 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
945 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
946
947 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
948 return false;
949 }
950 }
951 }
952
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000953 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000954 DeclarationName Corrected;
955 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS))) {
956 if (!R.empty()) {
957 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
958 if (SS.isEmpty())
959 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
960 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
961 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
962 else
963 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
964 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
965 << SS.getRange()
966 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
967 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
968 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
969 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
970 << ND->getDeclName();
971
972 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
973 return false;
974 }
975
976 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
977 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
978 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
979 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
980 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
981 // to recover well anyway.
982 if (SS.isEmpty())
983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
984 else
985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
986 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
987 << SS.getRange();
988
989 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
990 return true;
991 }
992 } else {
993 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
994 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000995 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000996 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000997 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000998 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000999 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1000 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001001 return true;
1002 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001003 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001004 }
1005
1006 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1007 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1008 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1009 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1010 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1011 << SS.getRange();
1012 return true;
1013 }
1014
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001015 // Give up, we can't recover.
1016 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1017 return true;
1018}
1019
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001020Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001021 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001022 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1023 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1024 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1025 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1026 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1027
1028 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001029 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001030
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001031 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001032
1033 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1034 DeclarationName Name;
1035 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1036 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001037 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1038 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001039
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001040 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001041
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001042 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1043 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001044 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1045 // (note: handled after lookup)
1046 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1047 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1048 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001049 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1050 // names a dependent type.
1051 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1052 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001053 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1054 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1055 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001056 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001057 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001058 TemplateArgs);
1059 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001060
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 // Perform the required lookup.
1062 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1063 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001065 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001067 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1068 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001069
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001070 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1071 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001072 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1073 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001074 if (E.isInvalid())
1075 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001076
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1078 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001079 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001080 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001081
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1083 return ExprError();
1084
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001085 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1086 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001087 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001088
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001090 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001091 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1092 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1093 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1094 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1095 }
1096
1097 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1098 // call, diagnose the problem.
1099 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001100 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001101 return ExprError();
1102
1103 assert(!R.empty() &&
1104 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001105
1106 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1107 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001108 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001109 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1110 R.clear();
1111 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1112 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1113 return move(E);
1114 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001115 }
1116 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001117
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001118 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1119 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1120
1121 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001122 // Warn about constructs like:
1123 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1124 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001125 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1126 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001127 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001128 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001129 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001131 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001132 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1133 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001134 break;
1135 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001137 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1138 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001139 }
1140 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001142 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1143 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1144 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1145 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1146 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1147 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001149 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001150
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001151 QualType T = Func->getType();
1152 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001153 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001154 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001156 }
1157 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001158
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001159 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1160 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1161 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1162 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1163 // class member access expression.
1164 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1165 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001166 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001168 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1169 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001170 }
1171
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001172 if (TemplateArgs)
1173 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001174
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1176}
1177
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001178/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1179Sema::OwningExprResult
1180Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1181 LookupResult &R,
1182 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1183 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1184 case IMA_Instance:
1185 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1186
1187 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1188 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1189 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1190 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1191
1192 case IMA_Mixed:
1193 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1194 case IMA_Unresolved:
1195 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1196
1197 case IMA_Static:
1198 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1199 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1200 if (TemplateArgs)
1201 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1202 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1203
1204 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1205 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1206 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1207 return ExprError();
1208 }
1209
1210 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1211 return ExprError();
1212}
1213
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001214/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1215/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1216/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1217/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001218Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001219Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 DeclarationName Name,
1221 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1222 DeclContext *DC;
1223 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) ||
1224 DC->isDependentContext() ||
1225 RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS))
1226 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1227
1228 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1229 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1230
1231 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1232 return ExprError();
1233
1234 if (R.empty()) {
1235 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1236 return ExprError();
1237 }
1238
1239 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1240}
1241
1242/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1243/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1244/// additional lookup.
1245///
1246/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1247/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1248///
1249/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1250Sema::OwningExprResult
1251Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001252 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001254 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001255
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001256 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1257 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1258 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1259 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1260 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1261
1262 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1263 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1264 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001265 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001266
1267 bool LookForIvars;
1268 if (Lookup.empty())
1269 LookForIvars = true;
1270 else if (IsClassMethod)
1271 LookForIvars = false;
1272 else
1273 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1274 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001275 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001276 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001277 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001278 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1279 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1280 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1281 if (IsClassMethod)
1282 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1283 << IV->getDeclName());
1284
1285 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1286 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1287 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1288 return ExprError();
1289
1290 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1291 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1292 return ExprError();
1293
1294 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1295 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1296 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1297 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1298
1299 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1300 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1301 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1302 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001303 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001304 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1305 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1306 SelfName, false, false);
1307 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1308 return Owned(new (Context)
1309 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1310 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1311 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001312 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001313 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001314 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001315 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1316 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1317 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1318 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1319 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1320 }
1321 }
1322
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001323 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1324 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1325 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1326 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1327 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1328 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1329 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1330 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1331 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1332 }
1333 }
1334 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001335 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1336 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001337}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001338
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001339/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1340///
1341/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1342///
1343/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1344/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1345/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1346/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1347///
1348/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1349/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1350/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1351/// the class declaring the member.
1352///
1353/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1354/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1355/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001356bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001357Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1358 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001359 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001360 NamedDecl *Member) {
1361 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1362 if (!RD)
1363 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001364
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001365 QualType DestRecordType;
1366 QualType DestType;
1367 QualType FromRecordType;
1368 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1369 bool PointerConversions = false;
1370 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1371 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001372
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001373 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1374 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1375 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1376 PointerConversions = true;
1377 } else {
1378 DestType = DestRecordType;
1379 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001380 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001381 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1382 if (Method->isStatic())
1383 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1386 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001387
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001388 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1389 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1390 PointerConversions = true;
1391 } else {
1392 FromRecordType = FromType;
1393 DestType = DestRecordType;
1394 }
1395 } else {
1396 // No conversion necessary.
1397 return false;
1398 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1401 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001402
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001403 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1404 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1405 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001406
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001407 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1408 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1409
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 // class name.
1413 //
1414 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1415 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1416 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1417 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1418 //
1419 // class Base { public: int x; };
1420 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1421 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1422 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1423 //
1424 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1425 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1426 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1427 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001429 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1430 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1431 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1432
1433 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1434
1435 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1436 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1437 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1438 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001441 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001445 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001446 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001447 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448
1449 FromType = QType;
1450 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1451
1452 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1453 // we're done.
1454 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1455 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 }
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1462 // down to the using declaration's type.
1463 //
1464 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1465 // class ever has member declarations.
1466 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1467 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1468 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1469 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1470
1471 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1472 // conversion is non-trivial.
1473 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1474 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001477 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 return true;
1479
1480 QualType UType = URecordType;
1481 if (PointerConversions)
1482 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001483 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001484 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 FromType = UType;
1486 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1487 }
1488
1489 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1490 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1491 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001493
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001501 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001503}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001504
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001505/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001506static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001507 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001508 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1509 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001510 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1511 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1512 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001513 if (SS.isSet()) {
1514 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1515 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001517
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001519 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001520}
1521
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001522/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1523/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1524/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1525/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001526Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1528 LookupResult &R,
1529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1530 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1532
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001533 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001534
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001535 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1536 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001537 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001539 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001540 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001542
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001543 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1544 // 'this' expression now.
1545 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1546 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1547 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001548 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1549 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1550 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1551 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001552 }
1553
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001554 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1555 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1556 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001557 SS,
1558 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1559 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001560}
1561
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001562bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001563 const LookupResult &R,
1564 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001565 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1566 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1567 return false;
1568
1569 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001570 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001571 return false;
1572
1573 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001574 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001575 return false;
1576
1577 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1578 // normal lookup:
1579 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1580 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1581
1582 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1583 // -- a declaration of a class member
1584 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1585 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001586 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001587 return false;
1588
1589 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1590 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1591 // using-declaration
1592 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1593 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1594 // turn off ADL anyway).
1595 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1596 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1597 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1598 return false;
1599
1600 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1601 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1602 // template
1603 // And also for builtin functions.
1604 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1605 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1606
1607 // But also builtin functions.
1608 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1609 return false;
1610 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1611 return false;
1612 }
1613
1614 return true;
1615}
1616
1617
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001618/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1619/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1620/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1621/// will in fact be used.
1622static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1623 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1624 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1625 return true;
1626 }
1627
1628 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1629 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1630 return true;
1631 }
1632
1633 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1634 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1635 return true;
1636 }
1637
1638 return false;
1639}
1640
1641Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001642Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001643 LookupResult &R,
1644 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001645 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1646 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001647 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001648 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001649
1650 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1651 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1652 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001653 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1654 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001655 return ExprError();
1656
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001657 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1658 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1659 // we've picked a target.
1660 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1661
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662 bool Dependent
1663 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001665 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001666 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1667 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001668 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1669 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001670 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001671
1672 return Owned(ULE);
1673}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001674
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001675
1676/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1677Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001678Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001679 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1680 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001681 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1682 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683
1684 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1685 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001686
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001687 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1688 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1689 // a template argument list.
1690 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1691 << Template << SS.getRange();
1692 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1693 return ExprError();
1694 }
1695
1696 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1697 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1698 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001699 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001700 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001701 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001702 return ExprError();
1703 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001704
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001705 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1706 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1707 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1708 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001709 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001710 return ExprError();
1711
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001712 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1713 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001714 return ExprError();
1715
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001716 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1717 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1718 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1719 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001720 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001721 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1722 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1723 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001724 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001725 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001726 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1727 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1728 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1729 return ExprError();
1730 }
1731
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001732 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001733 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1734 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1735 return ExprError();
1736 }
1737
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001738 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001739 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001740 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001741 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001742 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001743 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1744 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001745 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001746
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001747 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001748 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001749 constAdded));
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001750 }
1751 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1752 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001753
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001754 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001755}
1756
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001757Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1758 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001759 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001760
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001761 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001762 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001763 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1764 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1765 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001766 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001767
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001768 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1769 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001770
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001771 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1772 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001773 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001774 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001775 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001776
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001777 QualType ResTy;
1778 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1779 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1780 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001781 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001782
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001783 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001784 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001785 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1786 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001787 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001788}
1789
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001790Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001791 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001792 bool Invalid = false;
1793 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1794 if (Invalid)
1795 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001796
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001797 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1798 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001799 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001800 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001801
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001802 QualType Ty;
1803 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1804 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1805 else if (Literal.isWide())
1806 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001807 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1808 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001809 else
1810 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001811
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001812 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1813 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001814 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001815}
1816
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001817Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1818 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001819 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1820 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001821 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001822 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001823 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001824 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001825 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001826
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001827 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001828 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1829 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001830 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001831
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001832 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001833 bool Invalid = false;
1834 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1835 if (Invalid)
1836 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001837
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001838 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001839 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1840 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001841 return ExprError();
1842
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001843 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001844
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001845 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001846 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001847 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001848 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001849 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001850 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001851 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001852 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001853
1854 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1855
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001856 using llvm::APFloat;
1857 APFloat Val(Format);
1858
1859 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001860
1861 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1862 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1863 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1864 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001865 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001866 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001867 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001868 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001869 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1870 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001871 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001872 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1873 }
1874
1875 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1876 << Ty
1877 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1878 }
1879
1880 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001881 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001882
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001883 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001884 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001885 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001886 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001887
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001888 // long long is a C99 feature.
1889 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001890 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001891 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1892
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001893 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001894 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001895
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001896 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1897 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1898 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001899 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1900 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001901 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001902 } else {
1903 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1904 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001905
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001906 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1907 // be an unsigned int.
1908 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1909
1910 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001911 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001912 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1913 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001914 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001915
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001916 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1917 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1918 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1919 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001920 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001921 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001922 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001923 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001924 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001925 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001926
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001927 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001928 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001929 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001931 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1932 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1933 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1934 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001935 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001936 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001937 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001938 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001939 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001940 }
1941
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001942 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001943 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001944 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001946 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1947 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1948 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1949 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001950 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001951 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001952 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001953 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001954 }
1955 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001956
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1958 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001959 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001960 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001961 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001962 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001963 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001964
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001965 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1966 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001967 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001968 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001969 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001971 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1972 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001973 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001974 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
1976 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001977}
1978
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1980 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001981 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001982 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001983 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001984}
1985
1986/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
1987/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001988bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001989 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1990 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1991 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001992 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1993 return false;
1994
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001995 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1996 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1997 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1998 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
1999 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2000 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2001
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002002 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002003 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002004 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002005 if (isSizeof)
2006 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2007 return false;
2008 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002009
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002010 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002011 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002012 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2013 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002014 return false;
2015 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002016
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002017 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002018 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2019 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002020 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002021
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002022 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
Fariborz Jahanianced1e282009-04-24 17:34:33 +00002023 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002024 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002025 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2026 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002027 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002028
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002029 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002030}
2031
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002032bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2033 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2034 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002035
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002036 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002037 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2038 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002039
2040 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2041 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2042 return false;
2043
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002044 if (E->getBitField()) {
2045 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2046 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002047 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002048
2049 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2050 // bit-field.
2051 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002052 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002053 return false;
2054
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002055 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2056}
2057
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002058/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002059Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002060Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002061 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002062 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002063 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002064 return ExprError();
2065
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002066 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002067
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002068 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2069 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2070 return ExprError();
2071
2072 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002073 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002074 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2075 R.getEnd()));
2076}
2077
2078/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2079/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002080Action::OwningExprResult
2081Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002082 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2083 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2084 bool isInvalid = false;
2085 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2086 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2087 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2088 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002089 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002090 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2091 isInvalid = true;
2092 } else {
2093 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2094 }
2095
2096 if (isInvalid)
2097 return ExprError();
2098
2099 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2100 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2101 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2102 R.getEnd()));
2103}
2104
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002105/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2106/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2107/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002108Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002109Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2110 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002111 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002112 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002113
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002114 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002115 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2116 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2117 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002118 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002119
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002120 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2121 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2122 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2123
2124 if (Result.isInvalid())
2125 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2126
2127 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002128}
2129
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002130QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002131 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2132 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002133
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002134 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002135 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002136 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002137
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002138 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2139 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2140 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002141
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002142 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002143 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2144 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002145 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002146}
2147
2148
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002149
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002150Action::OwningExprResult
2151Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2152 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002153 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2154 switch (Kind) {
2155 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2156 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2157 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2158 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002159
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002160 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002161}
2162
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002163Action::OwningExprResult
2164Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2165 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002166 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2167 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2168
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002169 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2170 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002171
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002172 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002173 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2174 Base.release();
2175 Idx.release();
2176 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2177 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2178 }
2179
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002180 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002181 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002182 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2183 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2184 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002185 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002186 }
2187
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002188 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2189}
2190
2191
2192Action::OwningExprResult
2193Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2194 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2195 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2196 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2197
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002198 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002199 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2200 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2201 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002202
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002203 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002204
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002205 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002206 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002207 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002208 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002209 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2210 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002211 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2212 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2213 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2214 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002215 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2217 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002218 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002219 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002220 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002221 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2222 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002224 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002225 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002226 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2227 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2228 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002229 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002230 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002231 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2232 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2233 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2234 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002235 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002236 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002237 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002238
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002239 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2240 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002241 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2242 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002243 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002244 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2245 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2246 // force the promotion here.
2247 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2248 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002249 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2250 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002251 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2252
2253 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2254 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002255 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002256 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2257 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2258 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2259 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002260 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2261 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002262 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2263
2264 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2265 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002266 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002267 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002268 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2269 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002270 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002271 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002272 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2273 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002274 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2275 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002276
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002277 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002278 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2279 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002280 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2281
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002282 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002283 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2284 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002285 // incomplete types are not object types.
2286 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2287 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2288 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2289 return ExprError();
2290 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002291
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002292 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002293 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002294 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2295 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002296 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002297
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002298 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
2299 if (ResultType->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
2300 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2301 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2302 return ExprError();
2303 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002305 Base.release();
2306 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002307 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002308 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002309}
2310
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002311QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002312CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002313 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002314 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002315 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2316 // see FIXME there.
2317 //
2318 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2319 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002320 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002321
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002322 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002323 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002324
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002325 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002326 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2327 // to be selected.
2328 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002329
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002330 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2331 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002332 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002333
2334 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2335 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002337 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2338 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002339 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002340 do
2341 compStr++;
2342 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002343 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002344 do
2345 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002346 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002347 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002348
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002349 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002350 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2351 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002352 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2353 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002354 return QualType();
2355 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002357 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2358 // operates on.
2359 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002360 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002361
2362 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002363 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364
2365 while (*compStr) {
2366 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2367 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2368 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2369 return QualType();
2370 }
2371 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002372 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002373
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002374 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002375 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002376 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002377 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002378 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002379 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002380 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002381 if (HexSwizzle)
2382 CompSize--;
2383
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002384 if (CompSize == 1)
2385 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002386
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002387 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002388 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002389 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2390 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2391 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2392 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002393 }
2394 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002395}
2396
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002397static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002398 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002399 const Selector &Sel,
2400 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002401
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002402 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002403 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002404 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002405 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002407 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2408 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002409 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002410 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002411 return D;
2412 }
2413 return 0;
2414}
2415
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002416static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002417 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002418 const Selector &Sel,
2419 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002420 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2421 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002422 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002423 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002424 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002425 GDecl = PD;
2426 break;
2427 }
2428 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002429 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 GDecl = OMD;
2431 break;
2432 }
2433 }
2434 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002435 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002436 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2437 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002438 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002439 if (GDecl)
2440 return GDecl;
2441 }
2442 }
2443 return GDecl;
2444}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002445
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002446Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002447Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2448 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002449 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2450 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2451 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2452 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2453 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2454
2455 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2456 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2457 //
2458 // T* t;
2459 // t.f;
2460 //
2461 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2462 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2463 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2464 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002465 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002466 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2467 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002468 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002469 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002470 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002471 return ExprError();
2472 }
2473 }
2474
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002475 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
2476 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002477
2478 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2479 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002480 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002481 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2482 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2483 SS.getRange(),
2484 FirstQualifierInScope,
2485 Name, NameLoc,
2486 TemplateArgs));
2487}
2488
2489/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2490/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2491/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2492static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2493 Expr *BaseExpr,
2494 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002495 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002497 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2498 // diagnostics.
2499 if (!BaseExpr)
2500 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002501
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002502 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2503 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002504}
2505
2506// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2507// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2508// type. The restriction here is:
2509//
2510// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2511// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2512// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2513//
2514// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2515// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2516// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2517// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2518bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2519 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002520 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002521 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002522 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2523 if (!BaseRT) {
2524 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2525 // dependent.
2526 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2527 return false;
2528 }
2529 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002530
2531 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002532 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2533 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002534 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002535 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002536
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002537 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2538 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2539 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2540 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2541
2542 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2543 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2544
2545 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2546 return false;
2547 }
2548
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002549 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002550 return true;
2551}
2552
2553static bool
2554LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2555 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002556 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2558 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002559 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002560 << BaseRange))
2561 return true;
2562
2563 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2564 if (SS.isSet()) {
2565 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2566 // nested-name-specifier.
2567 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2568
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002569 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS)) {
2570 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2571 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2572 return true;
2573 }
2574
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002575 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002576
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002577 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2578 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2579 << DC << SS.getRange();
2580 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002581 }
2582 }
2583
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2585 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002586
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002587 if (!R.empty())
2588 return false;
2589
2590 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2591 // for typos.
2592 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002593 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
2594 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002595 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2596 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2597 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002598 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2599 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002600 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2601 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2602 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002603 return false;
2604 } else {
2605 R.clear();
2606 }
2607
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002608 return false;
2609}
2610
2611Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002612Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002613 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002614 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002615 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2616 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2617 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2618 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2619
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002620 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2621 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002622 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2624 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2625 Name, NameLoc,
2626 TemplateArgs);
2627
2628 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002629
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630 // Implicit member accesses.
2631 if (!Base) {
2632 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2633 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2634 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2635 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2636 OpLoc, SS))
2637 return ExprError();
2638
2639 // Explicit member accesses.
2640 } else {
2641 OwningExprResult Result =
2642 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002643 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002644
2645 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2646 Owned(Base);
2647 return ExprError();
2648 }
2649
2650 if (Result.get())
2651 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002652 }
2653
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002654 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002655 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2656 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657}
2658
2659Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2661 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2662 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002663 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002664 LookupResult &R,
2665 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2666 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002668 if (IsArrow) {
2669 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2670 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2671 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002672 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673
2674 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2675 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2676 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2677 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2678
2679 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002680 return ExprError();
2681
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002682 if (R.empty()) {
2683 // Rederive where we looked up.
2684 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2685 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2686 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002687
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002689 << MemberName << DC
2690 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002691 return ExprError();
2692 }
2693
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002694 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2695 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2696 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2697 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2698 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2699 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2700 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2701 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2702 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2703 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
2704 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002705 return ExprError();
2706
2707 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2708 // result.
2709 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002710 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002711 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002712 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002713 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002714
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002715 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2716 // pick a member.
2717 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2718
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002719 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2720 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2721 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2723 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002724 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2725 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2726 TemplateArgs);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002727 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728
2729 return Owned(MemExpr);
2730 }
2731
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002732 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002733 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2735
2736 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2737
2738 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2739 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2740 // error cases.
2741 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2742 return ExprError();
2743
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2745 if (!BaseExpr) {
2746 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002747 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002748 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2749
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002750 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2751 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2752 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2753 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002754 }
2755
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2757 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2758 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2759 // explicitly qualified.
2760 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2761 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2762 }
2763
2764 // Check the use of this member.
2765 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2766 Owned(BaseExpr);
2767 return ExprError();
2768 }
2769
2770 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2771 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2772 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002773 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2774 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2776 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2777
2778 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2779 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2780 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2781 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2782 else {
2783 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2784 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2785 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2786
2787 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2788 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2789
2790 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2791 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2792 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2793 }
2794
2795 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002796 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 return ExprError();
2798 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002799 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800 }
2801
2802 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2803 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2804 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002805 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2807 }
2808
2809 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2810 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2811 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002812 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002813 MemberFn->getType()));
2814 }
2815
2816 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2817 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2818 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002819 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 }
2821
2822 Owned(BaseExpr);
2823
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002824 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002826 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2827 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2828 else
2829 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2830 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002832 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2833 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002834 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002835 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836}
2837
2838/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2839/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2840/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2841/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2842/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2843/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2844/// an ordinary member expression.
2845///
2846/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2847/// fixed for ObjC++.
2848Sema::OwningExprResult
2849Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002850 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002851 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002853 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002854
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002855 // Perform default conversions.
2856 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002857
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002858 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002859 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2860
2861 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2862 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002863
2864 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002865 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002866 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2867 // call, and continue on.
2868 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2869 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2870 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2871 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2872 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2874 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002875 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2876 ->isRecordType()))) {
2877 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2878 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2879 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002880 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002881
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002882 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002883 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002884 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2885 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002887
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002888 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2889 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2890 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2891 }
2892 }
2893 }
2894
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002895 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2896 // use that.
2897 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002898 if (IsArrow) {
2899 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2900 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2901 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2902 if (OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
2903 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002904 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2905 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002906 }
2907 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002908 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2909 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2910 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2911 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002912 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002913 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002914 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002915
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002916 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2917 // use that.
2918 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2919 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2920 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2921 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2922 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2923 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2924 }
2925 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002926
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002927 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002928
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002929 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002930 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002931 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2932 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2933 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2934 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2935 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2936 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2937 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2938 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2939 // Check the use of this method.
2940 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2941 return ExprError();
2942 }
2943 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2944 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2945 Selector SetterSel =
2946 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2947 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2948 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2949 if (!Setter) {
2950 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2951 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002952 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002953 }
2954 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2955 if (!Setter)
2956 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002957
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002958 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2959 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002960
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002961 if (Getter || Setter) {
2962 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002963
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002964 if (Getter)
2965 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2966 else
2967 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2968 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2969 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002970 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002971 PType,
2972 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2973 }
2974 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2975 << MemberName << BaseType);
2976 }
2977 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002978
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002979 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2980 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2981 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002982 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002983 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002984
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002985 if (IsArrow) {
2986 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002987 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002988 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2989 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002990 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
2991 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
2992 // struct MyRecord foo;
2993 // foo->bar
2994 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
2995 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
2996 // by now.
2997 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
2998 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002999 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003000 IsArrow = false;
3001 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3003 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3004 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003005 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003006 } else {
3007 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3008 // type *foo;
3009 // foo.bar
3010 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3011 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3012 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3013 // the appropriate pointer type
3014 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3015 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3016 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3017 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3018 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003019 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003020 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3021 IsArrow = true;
3022 }
3023 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003025
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003026 // Handle field access to simple records. This also handles access
3027 // to fields of the ObjC 'id' struct.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003028 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003029 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3030 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003031 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003033 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003034
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003035 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3036 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
3038 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCInterfaceType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003039 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003040 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003041 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceType() : BaseType->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003042 if (IFaceT) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003043 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3044
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003045 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = IFaceT->getDecl();
3046 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003047 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003048
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003049 if (!IV) {
3050 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3051 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3052 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003053 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003054 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003055 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003056 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3057 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003058 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3059 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003060 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003061 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003062 }
3063 }
3064
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003065 if (IV) {
3066 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3067 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3068 // error cases.
3069 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3070 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003071
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003072 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3073 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3074 return ExprError();
3075 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3076 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3077 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3078 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3079 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3080 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3081 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3082 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3083 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3084 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3085 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3086 // AST for a function decl.
3087 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003088 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003089 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3090 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3091 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3092 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3093 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3094 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003095
3096 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3097 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003098 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003099 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003100 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003101 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3102 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003104 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003105 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003106
3107 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3108 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003109 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003110 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003111 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003112 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003113 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003114 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003115 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003116 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003117 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3118 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003119 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003120 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003121
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003122 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003123 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003124 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3125 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3126 // Check the use of this declaration
3127 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3128 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003129
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003130 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3131 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3132 }
3133 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3134 // Check the use of this method.
3135 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3136 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003137
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003138 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
3139 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3140 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3141 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003142 }
3143 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003144
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003145 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003146 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003147 }
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00003148
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003149 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3150 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003151 if (!IsArrow)
3152 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3153 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003154 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003155
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003156 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003157 if (!IsArrow &&
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003158 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003159 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003160 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003161 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003162
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003163 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003164 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003165 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003166 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3167 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003168 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003169 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003170 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003171 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003172
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003173 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3174 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3175
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003176 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003177}
3178
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003179/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3180/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3181/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3182/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3183/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3184///
3185/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3186/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3187/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3188/// only be called
3189/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3190/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3191/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3192Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3193 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3194 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003195 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003196 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3197 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3198 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3199 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3200 return ExprError();
3201
3202 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3203
3204 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3205 DeclarationName Name;
3206 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3207 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3208 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3209 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3210
3211 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3212
3213 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3214 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3215 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3216
3217 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3218 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3219
3220 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3221 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003222 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3223 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003224 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003225 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3226 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3227 Name, NameLoc,
3228 TemplateArgs);
3229 } else {
3230 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3231 if (TemplateArgs) {
3232 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3233 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
3234 } else {
3235 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003236 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003237
3238 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3239 Owned(Base);
3240 return ExprError();
3241 }
3242
3243 if (Result.get()) {
3244 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3245 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3246 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3247 // call now.
3248 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3249 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor77549082010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003250 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003251
3252 return move(Result);
3253 }
3254 }
3255
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003256 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003257 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3258 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003259 }
3260
3261 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003262}
3263
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003264Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3265 FunctionDecl *FD,
3266 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3267 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3268 Diag (CallLoc,
3269 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3270 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003271 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003272 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3273 } else {
3274 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3275 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3276
3277 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003278 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3279 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003280
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3282 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregord6350ae2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003283 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003284
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003285 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003286 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003287 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003289 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3290 InitializedEntity Entity
3291 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3292 InitializationKind Kind
3293 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3294 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3295 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3296
3297 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003298 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003299 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3300 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003301 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003302
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003303 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003304 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003305 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003306 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003308 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3309 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3310 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003311 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3312 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003313 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3314 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003315 }
3316
3317 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003318 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003319}
3320
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003321/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3322/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3323/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3324/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3325/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3326/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003327bool
3328Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003329 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003330 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003331 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3332 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003333 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003334 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3335 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003336 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003337
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003338 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3339 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3340 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3341 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3342 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003343 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
3344 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003345 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003346 }
3347
3348 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3349 // them.
3350 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3351 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3352 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3353 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003354 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
3355 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003356 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3357 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3358 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003359 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003360 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003361 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003362 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003363 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003364 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003365 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3366 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3367 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3368 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3369 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003370 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003371 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003372 if (Invalid)
3373 return true;
3374 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3375 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3376 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003377
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003378 return false;
3379}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003380
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003381bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3382 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3383 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3384 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3385 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3386 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003387 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003388 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3389 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3390 bool Invalid = false;
3391 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3392 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3393 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3394 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003395 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003396 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003397 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003398
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003399 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003400 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3401 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003402
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003403 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3404 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003405 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003406 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003407 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003408
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003409 // Pass the argument
3410 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3411 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3412 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003413
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003414
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003415 InitializedEntity Entity =
3416 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3417 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3418 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3419 SourceLocation(),
3420 Owned(Arg));
3421 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3422 return true;
3423
3424 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003425 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003426 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003427
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003428 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003429 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003430 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3431 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003432
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003433 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003434 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003435 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003436 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003437
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003439 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003440 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003441 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003442 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003443 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003444 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003445 }
3446 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003447 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448}
3449
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003450/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003451/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3452/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003453Action::OwningExprResult
3454Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3455 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003456 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003457 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003458
3459 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3460 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003461
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003462 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003463 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003464 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003465
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003467 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3468 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3469 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3470 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3471 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003472 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003473 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3474 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003475
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003476 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3477 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003478
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003479 NumArgs = 0;
3480 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003481
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003482 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3483 RParenLoc));
3484 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003485
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003486 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003487 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003488 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3489 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003490 bool Dependent = false;
3491 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3492 Dependent = true;
3493 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3494 Dependent = true;
3495
3496 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003497 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003498 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3499
3500 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3501 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3502 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3503 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3504
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003505 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3506
3507 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3508 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3509 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3510 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3511 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3512 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3513 // method template.
3514 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003515 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3516 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003517 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003518
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003519 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3520 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003521 }
3522
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003523 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003524 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003525 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003526 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003527 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3528 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003529 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003530
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003531 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003532 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003533 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3534 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003535 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003536 dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(BO->getType())) {
3537 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003538
3539 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3540 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003541 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3542 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003543
3544 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3545 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003546 TheCall.get(), 0))
3547 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003548
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003549 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003550 RParenLoc))
3551 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003552
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003553 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3554 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003555 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003556 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3557 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003558 }
3559 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003560 }
3561
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003562 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003563 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003564 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003565
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003566 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003567 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3568 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003569 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003570 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003571 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003572
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003573 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3574 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3575 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3576
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003577 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3578}
3579
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003580/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3581/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003582/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3583/// block-pointer type.
3584///
3585/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3586Sema::OwningExprResult
3587Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3588 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3589 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3590 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3591 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3592
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003593 // Promote the function operand.
3594 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3595
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003596 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3597 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003598 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3599 Args, NumArgs,
3600 Context.BoolTy,
3601 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003602
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003603 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3604 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3605 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3606 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003607 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003608 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003609 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3610 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003611 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003612 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003613 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003614 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003615 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003616 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003617 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3618 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3619
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003620 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003621 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003622 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3623 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003624 return ExprError();
3625
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003626 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003627 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003628
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003629 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003630 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003631 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003632 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003633 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003634 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003635
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003636 if (FDecl) {
3637 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3638 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3639 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6fb0aee2009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003640 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003641 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003642 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003643 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3644 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3645 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3646 }
3647 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003648 }
3649
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003650 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003651 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3652 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3653 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003654 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3655 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003656 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3657 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003658 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003659 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003660 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003661 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003662
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003663 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3664 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003665 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3666 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003667
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003668 // Check for sentinels
3669 if (NDecl)
3670 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003671
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003672 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003673 if (FDecl) {
3674 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3675 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003676
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003677 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003678 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3679 } else if (NDecl) {
3680 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3681 return ExprError();
3682 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003683
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003684 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003685}
3686
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003687Action::OwningExprResult
3688Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3689 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003690 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003691 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003692 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003693
3694 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3695 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3696 if (!TInfo)
3697 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3698
3699 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3700}
3701
3702Action::OwningExprResult
3703Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3704 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3705 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003706 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003707
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003708 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003709 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003710 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3711 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003712 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3713 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003714 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003715 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003716 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003717 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003718
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003719 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003720 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003721 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003722 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003723 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003724 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3725 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3726 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3727 &literalType);
3728 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003729 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003730 InitExpr.release();
3731 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003732
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003733 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003734 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003735 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003736 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003737 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003738
3739 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003740
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003741 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003742 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003743}
3744
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003745Action::OwningExprResult
3746Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003747 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3748 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3749 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003750
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003751 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003752 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003753
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003754 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3755 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003756 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003757 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003758}
3759
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003760static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3761 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003762 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003763 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3764
3765 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3766 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003767 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3768 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003769 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003770 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3771 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3772 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003773
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003774 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3775 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3776 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3777 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3778 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3779 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3780 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3781 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003782
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003783 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3784 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3785 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3786 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3787 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3788 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003789
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003790 // FIXME: Assert here.
3791 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3792 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3793}
3794
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003795/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003796bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003797 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003798 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003799 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003800 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003801 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3802 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003803
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003804 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003805
3806 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3807 // type needs to be scalar.
3808 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3809 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003810 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3811 return false;
3812 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003813
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003814 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003815 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003816 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3817 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003818 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003819 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3820 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003821 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003822 return false;
3823 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003824
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003825 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003826 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003827 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003828 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003829 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003830 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003831 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003832 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003833 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3834 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3835 break;
3836 }
3837 }
3838 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3839 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3840 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003841 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003842 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003843 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003844
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003845 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3846 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3847 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3848 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003849
3850 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003851 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003852 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3853 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003854 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003855 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003856
3857 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003858 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003859
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003860 if (castType->isVectorType())
3861 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3862 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3863 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3864
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003865 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3866 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003867
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003868 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003869 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3870 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3871 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3872 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3873 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3874 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3875 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3876 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3877 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3878 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003879 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003880
3881 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003882 return false;
3883}
3884
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003885bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3886 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003887 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003888
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003889 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003890 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003891 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003892 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003893 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003894 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003895 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003896 } else
3897 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003898 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003899 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003900
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003901 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003902 return false;
3903}
3904
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003905bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003906 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003907 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003908
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003909 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003910
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003911 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3912 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003913 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3914 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3915 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3916 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003917 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003918 return false;
3919 }
3920
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003921 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003922 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3923 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003924 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3925 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3926 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3927 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003928
3929 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3930 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3931 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003932
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003933 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003934 return false;
3935}
3936
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003937Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003938Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003939 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3940 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3941 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003942
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003943 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3944 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3945 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003946 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003947
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003948 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003949 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003950 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003951 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3952 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003953
3954 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3955}
3956
3957Action::OwningExprResult
3958Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3959 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3960 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3961
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003962 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003963 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003964 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003965 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003966 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003967
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003968 Op.release();
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003969 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003970 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003971 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003972}
3973
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003974/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
3975/// of comma binary operators.
3976Action::OwningExprResult
3977Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
3978 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
3979 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
3980 if (!E)
3981 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003982
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003983 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003984
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003985 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
3986 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
3987 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003988
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003989 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
3990}
3991
3992Action::OwningExprResult
3993Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3994 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003995 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003996 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003997 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003998
3999 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004000 // then handle it as such.
4001 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4002 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4003 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4004 return ExprError();
4005 }
4006
4007 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4008 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4009 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4010
4011 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4012 // braces instead of the original commas.
4013 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004014 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4015 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004016 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4017 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004018 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004019 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004020 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004021 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4022 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004023 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004024 }
4025}
4026
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004027Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004028 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004029 MultiExprArg Val,
4030 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004031 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4032 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004033 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4034 Expr *expr;
4035 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4036 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4037 else
4038 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004039 return Owned(expr);
4040}
4041
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004042/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4043/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004044/// C99 6.5.15
4045QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4046 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004047 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4048 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4049 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4050
John McCalld1b47bf2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00004051 CheckSignCompare(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
John McCallb13c87f2009-11-05 09:23:39 +00004052
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004053 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4054 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4055 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4056 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4057 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4058 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004059
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004060 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004061 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4062 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4063 << CondTy;
4064 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004065 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004066
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004067 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004068 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4069 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004070
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004071 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4072 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004073 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4074 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4075 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004076 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004077
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004078 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4079 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004080 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4081 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004082 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004083 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004084 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004085 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004086 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004087 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004088
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004089 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004090 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004091 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4092 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4093 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4094 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4095 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4096 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4097 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004098 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4099 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004100 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004101 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004102 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4103 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004104 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004105 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004106 // promote the null to a pointer.
4107 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004108 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004109 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004110 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004111 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004112 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004113 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004114 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004115
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004116 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4117 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4118 QuestionLoc);
4119 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4120 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004121
4122
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004123 // Handle block pointer types.
4124 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4125 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4126 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4127 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004128 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4129 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004130 return destType;
4131 }
4132 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004133 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004134 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004135 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004136 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4137 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4138 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004139 return LHSTy;
4140 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004141 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004142 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4143 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004144
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004145 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4146 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004147 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004148 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004149 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4150 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4151 // to get a consistent AST.
4152 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004153 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4154 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004155 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004156 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004157 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004158 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4159 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004160 return LHSTy;
4161 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004162
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004163 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4164 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4165 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004166 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4167 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004168
4169 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4170 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4171 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004172 QualType destPointee
4173 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004174 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004175 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4176 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4177 // Promote to void*.
4178 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 return destType;
4180 }
4181 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004182 QualType destPointee
4183 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004184 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004185 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004186 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004187 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004188 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004189 return destType;
4190 }
4191
4192 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4193 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4194 return LHSTy;
4195 }
4196 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4197 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4198 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4199 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4200 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4201 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4202 // to get a consistent AST.
4203 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004204 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4205 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004206 return incompatTy;
4207 }
4208 // The pointer types are compatible.
4209 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4210 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4211 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4212 // type.
4213 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4214 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004215 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4216 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004217 return LHSTy;
4218 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004219
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004220 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4221 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4222 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4223 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004224 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004225 return RHSTy;
4226 }
4227 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4228 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4229 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004230 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004231 return LHSTy;
4232 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004233
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004234 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004235 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4236 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004237 return QualType();
4238}
4239
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004240/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4241/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4242QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4243 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4244 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4245 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004246
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004247 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4248 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4249 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4250 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4251 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4252 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4253 return LHSTy;
4254 }
4255 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4256 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4257 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4258 return RHSTy;
4259 }
4260 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4261 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4262 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4263 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4264 return LHSTy;
4265 }
4266 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4267 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4268 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4269 return RHSTy;
4270 }
4271 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4272 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4273 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4275 return LHSTy;
4276 }
4277 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4278 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4279 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4280 return RHSTy;
4281 }
4282 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4283 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004284
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004285 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4286 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4287 return LHSTy;
4288 }
4289 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4290 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4291 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004292
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004293 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4294 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4295 // type. This allows
4296 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4297 // where B is a subclass of A.
4298 //
4299 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4300 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4301 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4302 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004303
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004304 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4305 // It could return the composite type.
4306 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4307 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4308 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4309 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4310 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4311 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4312 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4313 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4314 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4315 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4316 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4317 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4318 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4319 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004320 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004321 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4322 ;
4323 else {
4324 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4325 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4326 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4327 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4328 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4329 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4330 return incompatTy;
4331 }
4332 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4333 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4334 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4335 return compositeType;
4336 }
4337 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4338 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4339 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4340 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4341 QualType destPointee
4342 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4343 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4344 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4345 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4346 // Promote to void*.
4347 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4348 return destType;
4349 }
4350 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4351 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4352 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4353 QualType destPointee
4354 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4355 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4356 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4357 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4358 // Promote to void*.
4359 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4360 return destType;
4361 }
4362 return QualType();
4363}
4364
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004365/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004366/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004367Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4368 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4369 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4370 ExprArg RHS) {
4371 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4372 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004373
4374 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4375 // was the condition.
4376 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4377 if (isLHSNull)
4378 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004379
4380 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004381 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004382 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004383 return ExprError();
4384
4385 Cond.release();
4386 LHS.release();
4387 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004388 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004389 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004390 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004391}
4392
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004393// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004394// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004395// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4396// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4397// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004398Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004399Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4400 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004401
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004402 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4403 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4404 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4405 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4406 return Compatible;
4407 }
4408
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004409 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004410 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4411 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004412
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004413 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004414 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4415 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004416
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004417 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004418
4419 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4420 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4421 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004422 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004423 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004424 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004425
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004426 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4427 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004428 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004429 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004430 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004431 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004432
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004433 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004434 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4435 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004436 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004437
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004438 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004439 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004440 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004441
4442 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004443 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4444 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004445 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004446 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004447 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004448 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4449 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4450 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4451 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4452 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4453 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004454 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004455 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004456 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004457 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004458
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004459 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004460 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004461 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004462 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004463
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004464 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4465 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4466 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4467 // warning can be disabled.
4468 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4469 return ConvTy;
4470 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4471 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004472
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004473 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4474 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4475 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4476 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4477 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4478 do {
4479 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4480 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004481
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004482 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4483 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4484 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004485
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004486 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004487 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004488 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004489
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004490 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004491 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004492 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004493 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004494}
4495
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004496/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4497/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4498/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4499// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004500Sema::AssignConvertType
4501Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004502 QualType rhsType) {
4503 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004504
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004505 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004506 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4507 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004508
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004509 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4510 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4511 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004512
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004513 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004514
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004515 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004516 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004517 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004519 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4520 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4521 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4522 }
4523 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004524 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004525 return ConvTy;
4526}
4527
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004528/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4529/// for assignment compatibility.
4530Sema::AssignConvertType
4531Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004532 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4533 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004534 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4535 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004536 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004537 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004538 }
4539 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4540 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004541 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4542 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004543 return IncompatiblePointer;
4544 return Compatible;
4545 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004546 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004547 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004548 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004549 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4550 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4551 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4552 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4553 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4554 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004555
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004556 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4557 return Compatible;
4558 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4559 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004560 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004561}
4562
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004563/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4564/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004565/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4566///
4567/// int a, *pint;
4568/// short *pshort;
4569/// struct foo *pfoo;
4570///
4571/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4572/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4573/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4574/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4575///
4576/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004577/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004578///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004579Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004580Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004581 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4582 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004583 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4584 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004585
4586 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004587 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004588
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004589 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4590 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4591 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4592 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4593 return Compatible;
4594 }
4595
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004596 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4597 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4598 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4599 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4600 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4601 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4602 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004603 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004604 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004605 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004606 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004607 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004608 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4609 // to the same ExtVector type.
4610 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4611 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4612 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4613 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4614 return Compatible;
4615 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004616
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004617 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004618 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004619 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004620 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004621 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4622 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004623 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004624 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004625 }
4626 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004627 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004628
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004629 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004630 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004631
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004632 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004633 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004634 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004635
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004636 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004637 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004639 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004640 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004641 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4642 return Compatible;
4643 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004644 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004645 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4646 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004647 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004648
4649 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004650 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004651 return Compatible;
4652 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004653 return Incompatible;
4654 }
4655
4656 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4657 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004658 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004659
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004660 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004661 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004662 return Compatible;
4663
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004664 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4665 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004666
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004667 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004668 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004669 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004670 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004671 return Incompatible;
4672 }
4673
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004674 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4675 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4676 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004677
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004678 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004679 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004680 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4681 return Compatible;
4682 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004683 }
4684 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004685 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004686 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004687 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004688 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4689 return Compatible;
4690 }
4691 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4692 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4693 return Compatible;
4694 return Incompatible;
4695 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004696 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004697 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004698 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4699 return Compatible;
4700
4701 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004702 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004703
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004704 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004705 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004706
4707 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004708 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004709 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004710 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004711 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004712 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4713 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4714 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4715 return Compatible;
4716
4717 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4718 return PointerToInt;
4719
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004720 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004721 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004722 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4723 return Compatible;
4724 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004725 }
4726 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004727 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004728 return Compatible;
4729 return Incompatible;
4730 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004731
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004732 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004733 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004734 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004735 }
4736 return Incompatible;
4737}
4738
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004739/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4740/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004741static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004742 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4743 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4744 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004745 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004746 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004747 SourceLocation());
4748 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4749 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4750
4751 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4752 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004753 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004754 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004755 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004756}
4757
4758Sema::AssignConvertType
4759Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4760 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4761
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004762 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004763 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4764 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004765 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004766 return Incompatible;
4767
4768 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4769 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4770 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4771 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004772 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4773 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004774 it != itend; ++it) {
4775 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4776 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4777 // 1) void pointer
4778 // 2) null pointer constant
4779 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004780 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004781 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004782 InitField = *it;
4783 break;
4784 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004785
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004786 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004787 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004788 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004789 InitField = *it;
4790 break;
4791 }
4792 }
4793
4794 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4795 == Compatible) {
4796 InitField = *it;
4797 break;
4798 }
4799 }
4800
4801 if (!InitField)
4802 return Incompatible;
4803
4804 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4805 return Compatible;
4806}
4807
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004808Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004809Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004810 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4811 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4812 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4813 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4814 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004815 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004816 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004817 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004818 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004819 }
4820
4821 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4822 // structures.
4823 }
4824
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004825 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4826 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004827 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4828 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004829 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004830 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004831 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004832 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004833 return Compatible;
4834 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004835
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004836 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004837 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004838 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004839 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004840 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004841 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004842 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004843 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004844
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004845 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4846 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004847
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004848 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4849 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004850 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4851 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4852 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4853 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004854 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004855 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4856 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004857 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004858}
4859
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004860QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004861 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004862 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004863 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004864 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004865}
4866
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004867QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004868 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004869 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004870 QualType lhsType =
4871 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4872 QualType rhsType =
4873 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004874
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004875 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004876 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004877 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004878
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004879 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4880 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004881 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4882 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004883 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4884 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004885 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004886 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004887 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004888 }
4889 }
4890 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004891
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004892 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4893 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4894 bool swapped = false;
4895 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4896 swapped = true;
4897 std::swap(rex, lex);
4898 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4899 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004900
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004901 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004902 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004903 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4904 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4905 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004906 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004907 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4908 return lhsType;
4909 }
4910 }
4911 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4912 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4913 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004914 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004915 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4916 return lhsType;
4917 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004918 }
4919 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004920
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004921 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004922 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004923 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004924 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004925 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004926}
4927
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004928QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4929 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004930 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004931 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004932
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004933 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004934
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004935 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4936 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4937 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004938
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004939 // Check for division by zero.
4940 if (isDiv &&
4941 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004942 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004943 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004944
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004945 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004946}
4947
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004948QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004949 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004950 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4951 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4952 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4953 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4954 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004955
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004956 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004957
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004958 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4959 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004960
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004961 // Check for remainder by zero.
4962 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004963 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4964 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004965
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004966 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004967}
4968
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004969QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004970 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004971 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4972 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4973 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
4974 return compType;
4975 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00004976
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004977 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00004978
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004979 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004980 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
4981 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
4982 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004983 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004984 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004985
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00004986 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
4987 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004988 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00004989 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
4990
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004991 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004992
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00004993 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00004994 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004995
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00004996 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
4997 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00004998 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4999 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005000 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005001 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005002 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005003
5004 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5005 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5006 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005007 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005008 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5009 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5010 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5011 return QualType();
5012 }
5013
5014 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5015 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5016 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005017 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005018 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005020 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005021 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5022 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005023 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5024 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005025 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005026 return QualType();
5027 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005028 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5029 if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5030 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5031 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5032 return QualType();
5033 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005034
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005035 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005036 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5037 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5038 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5039 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5040 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005041 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005042 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5043 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005044 return PExp->getType();
5045 }
5046 }
5047
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005048 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005049}
5050
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005051// C99 6.5.6
5052QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005053 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5054 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5055 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5056 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5057 return compType;
5058 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005059
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005060 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005061
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005062 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005063
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005064 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005065 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5066 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005067 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005068 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005069 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005070
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005071 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005072 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005073 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005074
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005075 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005076
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005077 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5078 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5079 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5080 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5081 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5082 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5083 return QualType();
5084 }
5085
5086 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5087 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5088 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5089 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5090 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005091 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005092 return QualType();
5093 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005094
5095 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5096 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5097 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005098 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005099 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005100 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005101 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005102 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005103
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005104 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5105 if (lpointee->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5106 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5107 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5108 return QualType();
5109 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005110
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005111 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005112 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5113 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5114 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5115 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5116 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5117 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005118 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005119 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5120
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005121 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005122 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005123 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005124
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005125 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005126 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005127 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005128
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005129 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5130 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5131 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5132 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5133 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5134 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5135 return QualType();
5136 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005137
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005138 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5139 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5140 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005142 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005143 return QualType();
5144 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005145
5146 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5147 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5148 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5149 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5150 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005151 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5152 << rex->getSourceRange()
5153 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005155
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005156 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5157 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5158 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5159 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5160 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5161 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5162 return QualType();
5163 }
5164 } else {
5165 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5166 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5167 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5168 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5169 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5170 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5171 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5172 return QualType();
5173 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005174 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005175
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005176 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5177 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5178 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5179 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5180 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005181 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005182 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005183
5184 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005185 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5186 }
5187 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005189 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005190}
5191
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005192// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005193QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005194 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005195 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5196 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005197 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005198
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005199 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5200 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5201 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5202
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005203 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5204 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005205 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5206 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5207 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5208 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5209 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005210 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005211 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005212 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005213
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005214 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005215
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005216 // Sanity-check shift operands
5217 llvm::APSInt Right;
5218 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005219 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5220 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005221 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005222 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5223 else {
5224 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5225 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5226 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5227 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5228 }
5229 }
5230
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005231 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005232 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005233}
5234
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005235// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005236QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005237 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5238 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5239
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005240 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005241 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005242 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005243
John McCalld1b47bf2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00005244 CheckSignCompare(lex, rex, Loc, &Opc);
John McCall45aa4552009-11-05 00:40:04 +00005245
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005246 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff30bf7712007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005247 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5248 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5249 else {
5250 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5251 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5252 }
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005253 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5254 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005255
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005256 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5257 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005258 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5259 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5260 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005261 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenek9ecede72009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005262 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005263 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5264 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5265 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5266 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenekb82dcd82009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005267 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5268 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005269 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005270
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005271 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5272 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5273 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5274 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005275
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005276 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5277 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005278 Expr *literalString = 0;
5279 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005280 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005281 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005282 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005283 literalString = lex;
5284 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005285 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5286 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005287 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005288 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005289 literalString = rex;
5290 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5291 }
5292
5293 if (literalString) {
5294 std::string resultComparison;
5295 switch (Opc) {
5296 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5297 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5298 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5299 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5300 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5301 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5302 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5303 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005304
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005305 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5306 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5307 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005308 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005309 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005310 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005311
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005312 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005313 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005314
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005315 if (isRelational) {
5316 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005317 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005318 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005319 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005320 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005321 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005322
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005323 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005324 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005325 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005326
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005327 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005328 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005329 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005330 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005332 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5333 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5334 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005335 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005336 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005337 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005338 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005339 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005340
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005341 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005342 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5343 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005344 if (!isRelational &&
5345 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5346 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5347 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5348 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5349 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5350 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5351 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5352 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5353 return ResultTy;
5354 }
5355 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005356 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5357 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5358 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5359 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5360 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5361 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005362 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005363 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005364 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005365 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005366 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005367 if (T.isNull()) {
5368 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5369 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5370 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005371 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005372 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005373 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005374 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005375 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005376 }
5377
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005378 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5379 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005380 return ResultTy;
5381 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005382 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5383 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5384 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5385 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5386 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5387 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5388 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5389 }
5390 } else if (!isRelational &&
5391 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5392 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5393 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5394 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5395 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5396 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5397 }
5398 } else {
5399 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005400 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005401 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005402 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005403 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005404 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005405 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005406 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005407
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005408 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005409 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005410 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005411 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005412 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5413 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005414 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005415 return ResultTy;
5416 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005417 if (LHSIsNull &&
5418 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5419 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005420 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005421 return ResultTy;
5422 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005423
5424 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005425 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005426 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5427 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005428 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5429 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5430 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5431 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5432 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5433 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5434 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5435 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005436 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005437 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005438 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005439 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005440 if (T.isNull()) {
5441 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005442 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005443 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005444 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005445 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005446 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005447 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005448 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005449 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005451 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5452 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005453 return ResultTy;
5454 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005455
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005456 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005457 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5458 return ResultTy;
5459 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005460
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005461 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005462 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005463 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5464 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005465
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005466 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005467 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005468 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005469 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005470 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005471 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005472 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005473 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005474 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005475 if (!isRelational
5476 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5477 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005478 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005479 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005480 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005481 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005482 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5483 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5484 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005485 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005486 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005487 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005488 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005489
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005490 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005491 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005492 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5493 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005494 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005495 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005496 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005497 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005498
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005499 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5500 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005501 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005502 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005503 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005504 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005505 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005506 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005507 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005508 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005509 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5510 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005511 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005512 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005513 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005514 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005515 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005516 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5517 if (RHSIsNull) {
5518 if (isRelational)
5519 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5520 } else if (isRelational)
5521 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5522 else
5523 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005524
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005525 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005526 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005527 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005528 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005529 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005530 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005531 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005532 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005533 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5534 if (LHSIsNull) {
5535 if (isRelational)
5536 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5537 } else if (isRelational)
5538 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5539 else
5540 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005541
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005542 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005543 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005544 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005545 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005546 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005547 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005548 }
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005549 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005550 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5551 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005552 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005553 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005554 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005555 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5556 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005557 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005558 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005559 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005560 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005561}
5562
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005563/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005564/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005565/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5566/// types.
5567QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005568 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005569 bool isRelational) {
5570 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5571 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005572 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005573 if (vType.isNull())
5574 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005575
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005576 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5577 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005578
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005579 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5580 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5581 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5582 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5583 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5584 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5585 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005586 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005587 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005588
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005589 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5590 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5591 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005592 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005593 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005594
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005595 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5596 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5597 // elements for floating point vectors.
5598 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5599 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005600
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005601 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005602 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005603 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005604 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005605 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005606 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5607
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005609 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005610 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5611}
5612
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005613inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005614 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005615 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005616 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005617
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005618 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005620 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005621 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005622 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005623}
5624
5625inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005626 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005627 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5628 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5629 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005631 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5632 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005633
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005634 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005635 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005636
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005637 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5638 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5639 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5640 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5641 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5642 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5643 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005644
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005645 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005646 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005647 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005648
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005649 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5650 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5651 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5652 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005653
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005654 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005655 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005656 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005657
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005658 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5659 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5660 // The result is a bool.
5661 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005662}
5663
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005664/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5665/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5666/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5667///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005668static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005669 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5670 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5671 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5672 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005673 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005674 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5675 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5676 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5677 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005678 }
5679 }
5680 return false;
5681}
5682
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005683/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5684/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5685static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005686 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005687 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005688 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005689 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5690 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005691 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5692 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005694 unsigned Diag = 0;
5695 bool NeedType = false;
5696 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005697 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005698 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005699 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5700 NeedType = true;
5701 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005702 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005703 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5704 NeedType = true;
5705 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005706 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005707 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5708 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005709 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5710 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005711 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005712 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5713 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005714 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5715 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005716 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5717 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005718 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005719 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005720 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005721 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005722 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5723 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005724 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005725 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5726 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005727 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5728 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5729 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005730 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5731 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5732 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005733 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5734 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5735 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005736 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005737
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005738 SourceRange Assign;
5739 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5740 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005741 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005742 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005743 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005744 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005745 return true;
5746}
5747
5748
5749
5750// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005751QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5752 SourceLocation Loc,
5753 QualType CompoundType) {
5754 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5755 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005756 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005757
5758 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5759 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005760
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005761 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005762 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005763 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005764 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005765 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5766 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5767 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005768 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005769 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005770 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005771 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005772
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005773 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5774 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5775 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005776 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005777 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5778 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5779 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5780 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5781 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005782 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005783 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005784 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5785 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5786 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005787 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5788 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005789 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5790 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5791 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005792 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005793 }
5794 } else {
5795 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005796 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005797 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005798
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005799 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005800 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005801 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005802
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005803 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5804 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005805 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005806 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5807 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005808 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005809 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005810 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005811}
5812
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005813// C99 6.5.17
5814QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005815 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005816 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5817 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5818 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005819
5820 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5821 // incomplete in C++).
5822
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005823 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005824}
5825
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005826/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5827/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005828QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
5829 bool isInc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005830 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5831 return Context.DependentTy;
5832
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005833 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5834 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005835
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005836 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5837 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5838 if (!isInc) {
5839 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5840 return QualType();
5841 }
5842 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5843 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5844 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005845 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005846 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5847 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005848
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005849 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005850 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005851 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5852 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5853 << Op->getSourceRange();
5854 return QualType();
5855 }
5856
5857 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005858 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005859 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005860 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5861 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5862 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5863 return QualType();
5864 }
5865
5866 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005867 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005868 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005869 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005871 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005872 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005873 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5874 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5875 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5876 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5877 return QualType();
5878 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005879 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005880 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5881 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005882 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005883 } else {
5884 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005885 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005886 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005887 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005888 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005889 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005890 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005891 return QualType();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005892 return ResType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005893}
5894
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005895/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005896/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005897/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5898/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5899/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5900/// - &(x) => x
5901/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5902/// - &s.xx => s
5903/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5904/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5905/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5906/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005907static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005908 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005909 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005910 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005911 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005912 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5913 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5914 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005915 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005916 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005917 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005918 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005919 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005920 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5921 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005922 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5923 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5924 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5925 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5926 }
5927 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005928 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005929 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5930 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005931
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005932 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005933 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5934 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5935 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5936 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5937 default:
5938 return 0;
5939 }
5940 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005941 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005942 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005943 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005944 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5945 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005946 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005947 default:
5948 return 0;
5949 }
5950}
5951
5952/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005953/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005954/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005955/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005956/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005957/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005958/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005959QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005960 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
5961 op = op->IgnoreParens();
5962
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00005963 if (op->isTypeDependent())
5964 return Context.DependentTy;
5965
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00005966 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
5967 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
5968 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
5969 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
5970 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
5971 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
5972 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
5973 }
5974 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
5975 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
5976 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005977 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00005978 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00005979
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00005980 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
5981 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
5982 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
5983 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
5984 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
5985 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
5986 // branch of the if, below.
5987 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
5988 << dcl;
5989 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
5990
5991 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
5992 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
5993 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
5994 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005995 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
5996 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
5997 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
5998 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
5999 if (isSFINAEContext())
6000 return QualType();
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006001 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006002 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006003 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006004 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006005 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006006 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6007 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006008 return QualType();
6009 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006010 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006011 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6012 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6013 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006014 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006015 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006016 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006017 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006018 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006019 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006020 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6021 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6022 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6023 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6024 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006025 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6026 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006027 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6028 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006029 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6030 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006031 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006032 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006033 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6034 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6035 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006036 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6037 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006038 return QualType();
6039 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006040 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006041 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006042 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006043 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006044 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6045 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006046 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006047 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006048 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6049 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006050 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006051 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6052 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6053 return QualType();
6054 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006055
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006056 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6057 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006058 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006059 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006060 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006061 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006062 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006063 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6064 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006065 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6066 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6067 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006068 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006069 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006070
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006071 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6072 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6073 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6074 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6075 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6076 }
6077
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006078 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6079 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6080}
6081
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006082QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006083 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6084 return Context.DependentTy;
6085
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006086 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6087 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006088
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006089 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6090 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6091 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6092 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006093 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006094 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006095
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006096 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanian16b10372009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006097 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006098
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006100 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006101 return QualType();
6102}
6103
6104static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6105 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6106 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6107 switch (Kind) {
6108 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006109 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6110 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006111 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6112 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6113 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6114 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6115 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6116 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6117 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6118 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6119 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6120 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6121 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6122 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6123 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6124 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6125 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6126 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6127 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6128 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6129 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6130 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6131 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6132 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6133 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6134 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6135 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6136 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6137 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6138 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6139 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6140 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6141 }
6142 return Opc;
6143}
6144
6145static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6146 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6147 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6148 switch (Kind) {
6149 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6150 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6151 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6152 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6153 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6154 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6155 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6156 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6157 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006158 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6159 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6160 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6161 }
6162 return Opc;
6163}
6164
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006165/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6166/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6167/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006168Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6169 unsigned Op,
6170 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006171 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006172 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006173 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6174 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6175 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006176
6177 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006178 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6179 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6180 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006181 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6182 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6183 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6184 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6185 break;
6186 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006187 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006188 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6189 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006190 break;
6191 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6192 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6193 break;
6194 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6195 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6196 break;
6197 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6198 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6199 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006200 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006201 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6202 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6203 break;
6204 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6205 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6206 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6207 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006208 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006209 break;
6210 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6211 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006212 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006213 break;
6214 case BinaryOperator::And:
6215 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6216 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6217 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6218 break;
6219 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6220 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6221 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6222 break;
6223 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6224 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006225 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6226 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006227 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6228 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6229 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006230 break;
6231 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006232 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6233 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6234 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6235 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006236 break;
6237 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006238 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6239 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6240 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006241 break;
6242 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006243 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6244 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6245 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006246 break;
6247 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6248 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006249 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6250 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6251 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6252 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006253 break;
6254 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6255 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6256 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006257 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6258 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6259 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6260 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006261 break;
6262 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6263 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6264 break;
6265 }
6266 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006267 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006268 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006269 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6270 else
6271 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006272 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6273 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006274}
6275
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006276/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6277/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006278static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6279 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006280 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6281 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6282 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006283 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006284 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6285
6286 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6287 return;
6288
6289 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6290 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6291 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006292 return;
6293 }
6294
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006295 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6296 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006297 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006298
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006299 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006300 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006301
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006302 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6303 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6304 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6305 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006306 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006307 return;
6308 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006309
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006310 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006311 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6312 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006313}
6314
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006315/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6316/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6317/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6318/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006319static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6320 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006321 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6322 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6323 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6324 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006325 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006326 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006327 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6328
6329 // Subs are not binary operators.
6330 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6331 return;
6332
6333 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6334 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006335 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6336 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006337 return;
6338
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006339 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006340 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006341 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006342 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6343 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006344 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006345 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006346 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6347 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6348 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6349 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006350 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006351 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006352 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006353 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6354 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006355 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006356 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006357 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6358 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6359 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6360 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006361}
6362
6363/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6364/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6365/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6366static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6367 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006368 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006369 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6370}
6371
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006372// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006373Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6374 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6375 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006376 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006377 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006378
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006379 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6380 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006381
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006382 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6383 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6384
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006385 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6386}
6387
6388Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6389 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6390 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006392 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006393 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6394 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6395 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6396 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6397 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006398 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006399 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006400 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6401 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6402 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006403
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006404 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6405 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006406 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006407 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006408
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006409 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006410 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006411}
6412
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006413Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006414 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006415 ExprArg InputArg) {
6416 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006417
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006418 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006419 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006420 QualType resultType;
6421 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006422 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6423 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6424 break;
6425
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006426 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6427 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006428 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6429 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006430 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006431 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6432 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006433 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006434 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006435 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6436 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006437 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006438 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006439 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6440 break;
6441 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6442 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006443 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6444 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006445 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6446 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006447 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6448 break;
6449 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6450 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6451 break;
6452 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6453 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6454 resultType->isPointerType())
6455 break;
6456
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006457 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6458 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006459 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006460 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6461 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006462 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6463 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006464 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6465 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6466 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006467 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006468 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006469 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006470 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6471 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006472 break;
6473 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6474 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006475 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006476 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006477 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6478 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006479 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006480 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6481 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006482 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006483 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6484 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006485 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006486 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006487 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006488 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006489 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006490 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006491 resultType = Input->getType();
6492 break;
6493 }
6494 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006495 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006496
6497 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006498 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006499}
6500
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006501Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6502 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6503 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006504 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006505 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6506 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006507 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6508 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6509 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6510 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006511 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006512 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006513 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6514 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6515 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006516
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006517 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6518 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006519
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006520 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6521}
6522
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006523// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6524Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6525 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6526 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6527}
6528
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006529/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006530Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6531 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6532 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006533 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006534 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006535
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006536 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6537 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006538 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006539 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006540
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006541 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006542 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6543 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006544}
6545
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006546Sema::OwningExprResult
6547Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6548 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6549 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006550 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6551 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6552
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006553 bool isFileScope
6554 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006555 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006556 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006557
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006558 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6559 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6560 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006561
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006562 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6563 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6564 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006565
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006566 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6567 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6568 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6569 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6570 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006571
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006572 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006573 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006574 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006575
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006576 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6577 // expressions are not lvalues.
6578
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006579 substmt.release();
6580 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006581}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006582
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006583Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6584 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6585 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6586 TypeTy *argty,
6587 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6588 unsigned NumComponents,
6589 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6590 // FIXME: This function leaks all expressions in the offset components on
6591 // error.
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006592 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6593 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006594 assert(!ArgTy.isNull() && "Missing type argument!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006595
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006596 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6597
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006598 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6599 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6600 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006601 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006602 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006603
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006604 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6605 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
Douglas Gregor4fdf1fa2009-03-11 16:48:53 +00006606
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006607 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6608 // the offsetof designators.
6609 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6610 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006611 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006612 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
Eli Friedman1d242592009-01-26 01:33:06 +00006613
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006614 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6615 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006616 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6617 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006618 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006619 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6620 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006621
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006622 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006623 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006624
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006625 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6626 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6627 return ExprError();
6628
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006629 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6630 // leaks like a sieve.
6631 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6632 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6633 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6634 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6635 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6636 if (!AT) {
6637 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006638 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6639 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006640 }
6641
6642 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
6643
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006644 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6645 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006646 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006647
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006648 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6649 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006650 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006651 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006652 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006653 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006654 << Idx->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006655
6656 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6657 OC.LocEnd);
6658 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006659 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006660
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006661 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006662 if (!RC) {
6663 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006664 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6665 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006666 }
Chris Lattner704fe352007-08-30 17:59:59 +00006667
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006668 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6669 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006670 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006671 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6672 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6673 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6674 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6675 << Res->getType()))
6676 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006677 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006678
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006679 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6680 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
John McCallf36e02d2009-10-09 21:13:30 +00006681
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006682 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006683 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006684 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006685 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6686 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006687
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006688 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6689 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006690 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006691 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
John McCall09b6d0e2009-11-11 03:23:23 +00006692 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006693 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006694 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6695 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006696 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6697 // doesn't matter here.
6698 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
6699 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
6700 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006701 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006702 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006703
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006704 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6705 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006706}
6707
6708
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006709Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6710 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6711 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006712 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6713 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6714 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006715
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006716 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006717
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006718 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6719 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6720 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6721 return ExprError();
6722 }
6723
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006724 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6725 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006726}
6727
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006728Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6729 ExprArg cond,
6730 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6731 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6732 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6733 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6734 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006735
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006736 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6737
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006738 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006739 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006740 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006741 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006742 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006743 } else {
6744 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6745 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6746 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6747 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006748 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6749 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6750 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006751
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006752 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6753 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006754 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6755 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006756 }
6757
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006758 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6759 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006760 resType, RPLoc,
6761 resType->isDependentType(),
6762 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006763}
6764
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006765//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6766// Clang Extensions.
6767//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6768
6769/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006770void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006771 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6772 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6773 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6774 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006775}
6776
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006777void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006778 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006779 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006780
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006781 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6782 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006783 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006784 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6785
Mike Stump4eeab842009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006786 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6787 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6788 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6789 return;
6790 }
6791
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006792 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6793 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindola264ba482010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006794 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6795 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006796
6797 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
6798 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006799 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006800 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006801 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian3bba33d2009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006802 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006803 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6804 }
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006805 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006806
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006807 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6808 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6809 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6810 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
6811 return;
6812 }
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006813
6814 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006815 return;
6816 }
6817
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006818 // Analyze arguments to block.
6819 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
6820 "Not a function declarator!");
6821 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006822
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006823 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
6824 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006825
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006826 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
6827 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
6828 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
6829 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattnerb28317a2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00006830 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
6831 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006832 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006833 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006834 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00006835 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
6836 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
6837 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
6838 !Param->isImplicit() &&
6839 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
6840 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6841 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
6842 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
6843 }
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006844 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006845 }
Douglas Gregor838db382010-02-11 01:19:42 +00006846 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006847 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahaniand66f22d2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00006848 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006849 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006850
6851 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
6852 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
6853
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006854 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006855 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
6856 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
6857
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006858 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006859 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
6860 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
6861 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
6862
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006863 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006864 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006865 }
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006866
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006867 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006868 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006869 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006870 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian3bba33d2009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006871 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006872 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6873 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006874
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006875 // Analyze the return type.
6876 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006877 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006878
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006879 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6880 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6881 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6882 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
6883 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00006884 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006885}
6886
6887/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
6888/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
6889void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006890 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00006891 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006892 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006893 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006894}
6895
6896/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
6897/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006898Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6899 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00006900 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
6901 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
6902 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006903
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006904 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006905
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006906 PopDeclContext();
6907
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006908 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00006909 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
6910 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006911
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006912 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
6913 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
6914 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006915
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00006916 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006917 QualType BlockTy;
6918 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00006919 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola425ef722010-03-30 22:15:11 +00006920 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006921 else
Jay Foadbeaaccd2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00006922 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00006923 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola425ef722010-03-30 22:15:11 +00006924 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006925
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006926 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006927 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006928 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006929
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00006930 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006931 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00006932 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006933
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006934 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00006935
6936 bool Good = true;
6937 // Check goto/label use.
6938 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
6939 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6940 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
6941
6942 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
6943 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
6944 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
6945 continue;
6946
6947 // Emit error.
6948 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
6949 Good = false;
6950 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006951 if (!Good) {
6952 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00006953 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006954 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006955
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00006956 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00006957 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
6958 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
6959 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00006960
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006961 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
6962 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006963 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006964 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006965}
6966
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006967Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6968 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
6969 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006970 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00006971 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
6972 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006973
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00006974 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00006975
6976 // Get the va_list type
6977 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00006978 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
6979 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
6980 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
6981 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00006982 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00006983 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
6984 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
6985 } else {
6986 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
6987 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006988 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00006989 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00006990 return ExprError();
6991 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00006992
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00006993 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
6994 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006995 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
6996 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00006997 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00006998 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006999
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007000 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007001 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007002
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007003 expr.release();
7004 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7005 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007006}
7007
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007008Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007009 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7010 // pointers on the target.
7011 QualType Ty;
7012 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7013 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7014 else
7015 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7016
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007017 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007018}
7019
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007020static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
7021 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007022 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7023 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007024
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007025 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7026 if (!PT)
7027 return;
7028
7029 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7030 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7031 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7032 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7033 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7034 return;
7035 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007036
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007037 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7038 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7039 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7040 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007041
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007042 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007043}
7044
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007045bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7046 SourceLocation Loc,
7047 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007048 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7049 bool *Complained) {
7050 if (Complained)
7051 *Complained = false;
7052
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007053 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7054 bool isInvalid = false;
7055 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007056 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007057
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007058 switch (ConvTy) {
7059 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7060 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007061 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007062 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7063 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007064 case IntToPointer:
7065 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7066 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007067 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007068 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007069 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7070 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007071 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7072 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7073 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007074 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7075 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7076 break;
7077 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007078 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7079 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7080 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7081 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7082 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7083 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7084 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7085 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7086 // C++ semantics.
7087 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7088 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7089 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007090 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7091 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007092 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007093 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007094 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007095 case IntToBlockPointer:
7096 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7097 break;
7098 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007099 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007100 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007101 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007102 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007103 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7104 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7105 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007106 case IncompatibleVectors:
7107 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7108 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007109 case Incompatible:
7110 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7111 isInvalid = true;
7112 break;
7113 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007114
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007115 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7116 switch (Action) {
7117 case AA_Assigning:
7118 case AA_Initializing:
7119 // The destination type comes first.
7120 FirstType = DstType;
7121 SecondType = SrcType;
7122 break;
7123
7124 case AA_Returning:
7125 case AA_Passing:
7126 case AA_Converting:
7127 case AA_Sending:
7128 case AA_Casting:
7129 // The source type comes first.
7130 FirstType = SrcType;
7131 SecondType = DstType;
7132 break;
7133 }
7134
7135 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007136 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007137 if (Complained)
7138 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007139 return isInvalid;
7140}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007141
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007142bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007143 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7144 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7145 if (Result)
7146 *Result = ICEResult;
7147 return false;
7148 }
7149
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007150 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7151
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007152 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007153 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7154 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7155
7156 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7157 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7158 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7159 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7160 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7161 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7162 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007163
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007164 return true;
7165 }
7166
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007167 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7168 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007169
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007170 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7171 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7172 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007173
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007174 if (Result)
7175 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7176 return false;
7177}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007178
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007179void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007180Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007181 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7182 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007183}
7184
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007185void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007186Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7187 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7188 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7189 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007190
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007191 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7192 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7193 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7194 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7195 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007196 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007197 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7198 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7199 I != IEnd; ++I)
7200 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7201 }
7202
7203 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7204 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7205 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7206 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7207 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7208 I != IEnd; ++I)
7209 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7210 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007211 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007212
7213 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7214 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7215 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7216 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007217 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007218 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7219 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7220 ExprTemporaries.end());
7221
7222 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7223 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007224}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007225
7226/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7227///
7228/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7229/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7230/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7231/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7232///
7233/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7234///
7235/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7236void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7237 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007238
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007239 if (D->isUsed())
7240 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007241
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007242 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7243 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7244 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7245 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007246 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007247 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007248 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007249 return;
7250 }
7251
7252 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7253 return;
7254
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007255 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7256 // an instantiation.
7257 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7258 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007259
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007260 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007261 case Unevaluated:
7262 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7263 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007264
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007265 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7266 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7267 // "used"; handle this below.
7268 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007269
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007270 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7271 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7272 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7273 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007274 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007275 return;
7276 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007277
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007278 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007279 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007280 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007281 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7282 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7283 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007284 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007285 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007286 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7287 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7288 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007289
Anders Carlssond6a637f2009-12-07 08:24:59 +00007290 MaybeMarkVirtualMembersReferenced(Loc, Constructor);
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007291 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7292 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7293 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007294
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007295 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7296 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7297 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7298 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
7299 DefineImplicitOverloadedAssign(Loc, MethodDecl);
7300 }
7301 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007302 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007303 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007304 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007305 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007306 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7307 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7308 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7309 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7310 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007311 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007312 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007313 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007314 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007315 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7316 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7317 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007318 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007319 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007320 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7321 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007322
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007323 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7324 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7325 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7326 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7327 Loc));
7328 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007329 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007330 Loc));
7331 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007332 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007333
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007334 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007335 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007336
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007337 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007338 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007339
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007340 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007341 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007342 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007343 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7344 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7345 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7346 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7347 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7348 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7349 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7350 }
7351 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007352
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007353 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007354
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007355 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007356 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007357 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007358}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007359
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007360/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7361/// of the program being compiled.
7362///
7363/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007364/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007365/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7366/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7367/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7368/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007369/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007370/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007371///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007372/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7373/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7374/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7375/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007376bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007377 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7378 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7379 case Unevaluated:
7380 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7381 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007382
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007383 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7384 Diag(Loc, PD);
7385 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007386
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007387 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7388 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7389 break;
7390 }
7391
7392 return false;
7393}
7394
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007395bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7396 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7397 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7398 return false;
7399
7400 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7401 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7402 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7403 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007404
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007405 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007406 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007407 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7408 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007409 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007410 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7411 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7412 return true;
7413
7414 return false;
7415}
7416
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007417// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7418// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7419void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7420 SourceLocation Loc;
7421
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007422 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7423
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007424 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7425 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7426 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7427 return;
7428
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007429 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7430 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7431 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7432 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7433
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007434 // self = [<foo> init...]
7435 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7436 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7437 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7438
7439 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7440 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7441 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7442 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7443 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007444
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007445 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7446 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7447 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7448 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7449 return;
7450
7451 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7452 } else {
7453 // Not an assignment.
7454 return;
7455 }
7456
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007457 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007458 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007459
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007460 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007461 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007462 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007463 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7464 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7465 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007466}
7467
7468bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7469 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7470
7471 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007472 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007473
7474 QualType T = E->getType();
7475
7476 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7477 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7478 return true;
7479 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7480 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7481 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7482 return true;
7483 }
7484 }
7485
7486 return false;
7487}